xref: /openbmc/linux/include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h (revision 726ccdba)
1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3 /*
4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5  *
6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14  * Copyright (C) 2018-2022 Intel Corporation
15  *
16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19  *
20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27  *
28  */
29 
30 /*
31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34  *
35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39  * can actually be identified and removed.
40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41  */
42 
43 #include <linux/types.h>
44 
45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46 
47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54 
55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59 
60 /**
61  * DOC: Station handling
62  *
63  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67  * to.
68  *
69  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70  * capabilities.
71  *
72  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75  *    or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions
76  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78  *    time mark it authorized.
79  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82  *
83  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84  */
85 
86 /**
87  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88  *
89  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames
91  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93  * for various reasons.
94  *
95  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101  * for doing that.
102  *
103  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106  *
107  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113  *
114  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its
117  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118  *
119  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120  * below.
121  */
122 
123 /**
124  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125  *
126  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have
127  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130  *
131  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133  * types there no concurrency is implied.
134  *
135  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138  * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and
139  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142  *
143  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151  *
152  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153  * interfaces that a given device supports.
154  */
155 
156 /**
157  * DOC: packet coalesce support
158  *
159  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162  * and power consumption.
163  *
164  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167  * following events occur.
168  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches it's limit.
171  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172  *
173  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174  * rule.
175  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177  * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178  * Multiple such rules can be created.
179  */
180 
181 /**
182  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183  *
184  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186  * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191  *
192  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195  * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196  * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197  * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198  * not present.
199  *
200  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202  * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207  *
208  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211  */
212 
213 /**
214  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215  *
216  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by
217  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231  *
232  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234  * up a connection or after roaming.
235  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241  *
242  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS
243  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249  */
250 
251 /**
252  * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253  *
254  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255  * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256  * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257  * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258  *
259  * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261  * respectively.
262  */
263 
264 /**
265  * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266  *
267  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268  * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269  * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270  * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271  * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272  * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273  * that main netdev.
274  *
275  * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277  * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278  */
279 
280 /**
281  * DOC: TID configuration
282  *
283  * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284  * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285  *
286  * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287  * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289  *
290  * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291  * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292  * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293  * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294  * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values
295  * will be overwritten.
296  *
297  * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection
298  * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299  * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300  * the interface goes down.
301  */
302 
303 /**
304  * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
305  *
306  * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
307  *
308  * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
309  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
310  * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
311  * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
312  * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
313  *
314  * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
315  * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
316  * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
317  * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
318  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
319  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
320  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
321  *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
322  *
323  * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
324  */
325 
326 /**
327  * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
328  *
329  * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between to MLDs utilizes multiple
330  * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
331  * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
332  * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
333  * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
334  * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
335  */
336 
337 /**
338  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
339  *
340  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
341  *
342  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
343  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
344  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
345  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
346  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
347  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
348  *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
349  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
350  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
351  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
352  *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
353  *	compatibility only.
354  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
355  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
356  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
357  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
358  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
359  *
360  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
361  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
362  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
363  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
364  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
365  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
366  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
367  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
368  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
369  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
370  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
371  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
372  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
373  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
374  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
375  *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
376  *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
377  *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
378  *
379  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
380  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
381  *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
382  *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
383  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
384  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
385  *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
386  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
387  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
388  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
389  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
390  *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
391  *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
392  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
393  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
394  *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
395  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
396  *
397  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
398  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
399  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
400  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
401  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
402  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
403  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
404  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
405  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
406  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
407  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
408  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
409  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
410  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
411  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
412  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
413  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
414  *	attributes determining channel width.
415  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
416  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
417  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
418  *
419  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
420  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
421  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
422  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
423  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
424  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
425  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
426  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
427  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
428  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
429  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
430  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
431  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
432  *	frame).
433  *
434  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
435  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
436  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
437  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
438  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
439  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
440  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
441  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
442  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
443  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
444  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
445  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
446  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
447  *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
448  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
449  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
450  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
451  *
452  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
453  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
454  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
455  *	global regdomain will be returned.
456  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
457  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
458  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
459  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
460  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
461  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
462  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
463  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
464  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
465  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
466  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
467  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
468  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
469  * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
470  * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
471  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
472  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
473  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
474  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
475  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
476  * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
477  * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
478  *
479  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
480  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
481  *
482  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
483  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
484  *
485  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
486  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
487  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
488  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
489  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
490  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
491  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
492  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
493  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
494  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
495  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
496  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
497  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
498  *
499  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
500  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
501  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
502  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
503  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
504  *	be used.
505  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
506  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
507  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
508  *	partial scan results may be available
509  *
510  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
511  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
512  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
513  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
514  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
515  *	These attributes are mutually exculsive,
516  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
517  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
518  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
519  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
520  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
521  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
522  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
523  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
524  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
525  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
526  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
527  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
528  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
529  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
530  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
531  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
532  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
533  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
534  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
535  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
536  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
537  *	results available.
538  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
539  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
540  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
541  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
542  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
543  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
544  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
545  *
546  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation
547  *      or noise level
548  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
549  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
550  *
551  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
552  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
553  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
554  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
555  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
556  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
557  *	advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
558  *	ESS.
559  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
560  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
561  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
562  *	authentication.
563  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
564  *
565  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
566  * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
567  * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
568  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
569  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
570  * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
571  * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
572  * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
573  * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
574  * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
575  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
576  * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
577  * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
578  * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
579  * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
580  * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
581  * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
582  * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
583  * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
584  * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
585  * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
586  * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
587  * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
588  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
589  * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
590  * 	the beacon hint was processed.
591  *
592  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
593  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
594  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
595  *	authentication process.
596  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
597  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
598  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
599  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
600  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
601  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the
602  *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
603  *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
604  *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
605  *	to the frame.
606  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
607  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
608  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
609  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
610  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
611  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
612  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
613  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
614  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
615  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
616  *	pending authentication timed out).
617  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
618  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
619  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
620  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
621  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
622  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
623  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
624  *	included).
625  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
626  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
627  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
628  *	primitives).
629  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
630  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
631  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
632  *
633  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
634  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
635  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
636  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
637  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
638  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
639  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
640  *
641  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
642  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
643  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
644  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
645  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
646  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
647  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
648  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
649  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
650  *	determined by the network interface.
651  *
652  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
653  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
654  *	to the driver.
655  *
656  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
657  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
658  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
659  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
660  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
661  *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
662  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
663  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
664  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
665  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
666  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
667  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
668  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
669  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
670  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
671  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
672  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
673  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
674  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
675  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
676  *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
677  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
678  *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
679  *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
680  *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
681  *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
682  *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
683  *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
684  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
685  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
686  *	a different BSS is desired.
687  *	Background scan period can optionally be
688  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
689  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
690  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
691  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
692  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
693  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
694  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
695  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
696  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
697  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
698  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
699  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
700  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
701  *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
702  *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
703  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
704  *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
705  *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
706  *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
707  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
708  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
709  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
710  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
711  *
712  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
713  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
714  *
715  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
716  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
717  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
718  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
719  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
720  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
721  *	frequency for the operation.
722  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
723  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
724  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
725  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
726  *	radio).
727  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
728  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
729  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
730  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
731  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
732  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
733  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
734  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
735  *	uniquely identify the request.
736  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
737  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
738  *
739  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
740  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
741  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
742  *
743  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
744  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
745  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
746  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
747  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
748  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
749  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
750  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
751  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
752  *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
753  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
754  *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
755  *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
756  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
757  *	backward compatibility
758  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
759  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
760  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
761  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
762  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
763  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
764  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
765  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
766  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
767  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
768  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
769  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
770  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
771  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
772  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
773  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
774  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
775  *	is used during CSA period.
776  *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
777  *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
778  *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
779  *	lower layers.
780  *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
781  *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
782  *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
783  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
784  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
785  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
786  *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
787  *	wait time.
788  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
789  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
790  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
791  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
792  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
793  *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
794  *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
795  *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
796  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
797  *	backward compatibility.
798  *
799  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
800  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
801  *
802  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
803  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
804  *	levels.
805  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
806  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
807  *	reached.
808  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
809  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
810  *	(identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
811  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
812  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
813  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
814  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
815  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
816  *	precedence when they are used.
817  *
818  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
819  *	(no longer supported).
820  *
821  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
822  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
823  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
824  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
825  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
826  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
827  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
828  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
829  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
830  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
831  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
832  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
833  *	command, the feature is disabled.
834  *
835  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
836  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
837  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
838  *	network is determined by the network interface.
839  *
840  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
841  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
842  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
843  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
844  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
845  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
846  *
847  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
848  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
849  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
850  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
851  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
852  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
853  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
854  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
855  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
856  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
857  *      depending on the authentication result.
858  *
859  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
860  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
861  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
862  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
863  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
864  *	more background information, see
865  *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
866  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
867  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
868  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
869  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
870  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
871  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
872  *
873  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
874  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
875  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
876  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
877  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
878  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
879  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
880  *
881  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
882  *	of PMKSA caching dandidates.
883  *
884  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
885  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
886  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
887  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
888  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
889  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
890  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
891  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
892  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
893  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
894  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
895  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
896  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
897  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
898  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
899  *
900  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
901  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
902  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
903  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
904  *	is received.
905  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
906  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
907  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
908  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
909  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
910  *
911  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
912  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
913  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
914  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
915  *
916  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
917  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
918  *	acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
919  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
920  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
921  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
922  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
923  *
924  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
925  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
926  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
927  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
928  *
929  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
930  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
931  *
932  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
933  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
934  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
935  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
936  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
937  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
938  *
939  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
940  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
941  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
942  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
943  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
944  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
945  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
946  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
947  *
948  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
949  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
950  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
951  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
952  *	public action frame TX.
953  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
954  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
955  *
956  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
957  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
958  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
959  *	is used for this.
960  *
961  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
962  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
963  *
964  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
965  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
966  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
967  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
968  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
969  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
970  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
971  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
972  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
973  *
974  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
975  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
976  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
977  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
978  *	while operating on this channel.
979  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
980  *	event.
981  *
982  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
983  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
984  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
985  *
986  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
987  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
988  *
989  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
990  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
991  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
992  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
993  *
994  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
995  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
996  *	complete.
997  *
998  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
999  *	return back to normal.
1000  *
1001  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
1002  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
1003  *
1004  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
1005  *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
1006  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
1007  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
1008  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
1009  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
1010  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
1011  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
1012  *	switch is complete.
1013  *
1014  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
1015  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
1016  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
1017  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
1018  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
1019  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
1020  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
1021  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
1022  *
1023  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
1024  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
1025  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
1026  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
1027  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
1028  *
1029  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
1030  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
1031  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
1032  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
1033  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
1034  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
1035  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
1036  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
1037  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
1038  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
1039  *	fail even if the check was successful.
1040  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
1041  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
1042  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
1043  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
1044  *
1045  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
1046  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
1047  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
1048  *
1049  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
1050  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
1051  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
1052  *	network is determined by the network interface.
1053  *
1054  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1055  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1056  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1057  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1058  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1059  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1060  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1061  *	AP.
1062  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1063  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1064  *	when this command completes.
1065  *
1066  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1067  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1068  *	management.
1069  *
1070  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1071  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1072  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1073  *
1074  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1075  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1076  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1077  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1078  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1079  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1080  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1081  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1082  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1083  *	added.
1084  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1085  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1086  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1087  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1088  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1089  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1090  *	of the function upon success.
1091  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1092  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1093  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1094  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1095  *	which just terminated.
1096  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1097  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1098  *	the response to this command.
1099  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1100  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1101  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1102  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1103  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1104  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1105  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1106  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1107  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1108  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1109  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1110  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1111  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1112  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1113  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1114  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1115  *
1116  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1117  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1118  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1119  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1120  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1121  *
1122  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1123  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1124  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1125  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1126  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1127  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1128  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1129  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates an 802.1X FT roam was
1130  *	completed successfully. Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload
1131  *	should send this event after indicating 802.1X FT assocation with
1132  *	%NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT
1133  *	should be indicated instead.
1134  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1135  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1136  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1137  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1138  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1139  *	802.11 headers.
1140  *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
1141  *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
1142  *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
1143  *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
1144  *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
1145  *	address of that link.
1146  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1147  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1148  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1149  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1150  *
1151  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1152  *
1153  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1154  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1155  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1156  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1157  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1158  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1159  *
1160  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1161  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1162  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1163  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1164  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1165  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1166  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1167  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1168  *	command interface.
1169  *
1170  *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
1171  *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
1172  *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
1173  *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
1174  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
1175  *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
1176  *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
1177  *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
1178  *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
1179  *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
1180  *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
1181  *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
1182  *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
1183  *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
1184  *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
1185  *	authentication.
1186  *
1187  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1188  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1189  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1190  *
1191  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1192  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1193  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1194  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1195  *
1196  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1197  *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1198  *
1199  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1200  *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1201  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1202  *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1203  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1204  *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1205  *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1206  *	the netlink extended ack message.
1207  *
1208  *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1209  *
1210  *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1211  *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1212  *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1213  *	buffer size.
1214  *
1215  *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1216  *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1217  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1218  *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1219  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1220  *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1221  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1222  *
1223  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1224  *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1225  *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1226  *	determining the width and type.
1227  *
1228  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1229  *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1230  *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1231  *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1232  *
1233  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1234  *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1235  *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1236  *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1237  *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1238  *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1239  *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1240  *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1241  *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1242  *	rate selection.
1243  *
1244  *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1245  *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1246  *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1247  *
1248  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1249  *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1250  *
1251  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1252  *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1253  *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1254  *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1255  *
1256  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1257  *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1258  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1259  *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1260  *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1261  *
1262  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1263  *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1264  *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1265  *
1266  * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
1267  *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
1268  *
1269  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
1270  *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
1271  *
1272  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
1273  *	started
1274  *
1275  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
1276  *	been aborted
1277  *
1278  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
1279  *	has completed
1280  *
1281  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
1282  *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
1283  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
1284  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
1285  *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
1286  *
1287  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
1288  *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1289  *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
1290  *      specify the timeout value.
1291  *
1292  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
1293  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
1294  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
1295  *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
1296  *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
1297  *
1298  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
1299  * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
1300  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
1301  *
1302  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP: Enable/disable HW timestamping of Timing
1303  *	measurement and Fine timing measurement frames. If %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1304  *	is included, enable/disable HW timestamping only for frames to/from the
1305  *	specified MAC address. Otherwise enable/disable HW timestamping for
1306  *	all TM/FTM frames (including ones that were enabled with specific MAC
1307  *	address). If %NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED is not included, disable
1308  *	HW timestamping.
1309  *	The number of peers that HW timestamping can be enabled for concurrently
1310  *	is indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS.
1311  *
1312  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1313  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1314  */
1315 enum nl80211_commands {
1316 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1317 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1318 
1319 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1320 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1321 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1322 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1323 
1324 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1325 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1326 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1327 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1328 
1329 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1330 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1331 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1332 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1333 
1334 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1335 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1336 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1337 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1338 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1339 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1340 
1341 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1342 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1343 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1344 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1345 
1346 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1347 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1348 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1349 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1350 
1351 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1352 
1353 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1354 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1355 
1356 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1357 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1358 
1359 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1360 
1361 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1362 
1363 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1364 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1365 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1366 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1367 
1368 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1369 
1370 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1371 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1372 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1373 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1374 
1375 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1376 
1377 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1378 
1379 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1380 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1381 
1382 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1383 
1384 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1385 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1386 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1387 
1388 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1389 
1390 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1391 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1392 
1393 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1394 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1395 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1396 
1397 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1398 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1399 
1400 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1401 
1402 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1403 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1404 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1405 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1406 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1407 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1408 
1409 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1410 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1411 
1412 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1413 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1414 
1415 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1416 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1417 
1418 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1419 
1420 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1421 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1422 
1423 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1424 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1425 
1426 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1427 
1428 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1429 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1430 
1431 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1432 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1433 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1434 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1435 
1436 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1437 
1438 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1439 
1440 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1441 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1442 
1443 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1444 
1445 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1446 
1447 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1448 
1449 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1450 
1451 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1452 
1453 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1454 
1455 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1456 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1457 
1458 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1459 
1460 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1461 
1462 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1463 
1464 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1465 
1466 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1467 
1468 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1469 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1470 
1471 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1472 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1473 
1474 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1475 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1476 
1477 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1478 
1479 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1480 
1481 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1482 
1483 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1484 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1485 
1486 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1487 
1488 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1489 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1490 
1491 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1492 
1493 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1494 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1495 
1496 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1497 
1498 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1499 
1500 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1501 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1502 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1503 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1504 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1505 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1506 
1507 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1508 
1509 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1510 
1511 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1512 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1513 
1514 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1515 
1516 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1517 
1518 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1519 
1520 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1521 
1522 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1523 
1524 	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1525 
1526 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1527 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1528 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1529 
1530 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1531 
1532 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1533 
1534 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1535 
1536 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1537 
1538 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1539 
1540 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1541 
1542 	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1543 
1544 	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
1545 
1546 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
1547 
1548 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
1549 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
1550 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
1551 
1552 	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
1553 
1554 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
1555 
1556 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
1557 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
1558 
1559 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
1560 	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
1561 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
1562 
1563 	NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP,
1564 
1565 	/* add new commands above here */
1566 
1567 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1568 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1569 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1570 };
1571 
1572 /*
1573  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1574  * here
1575  */
1576 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1577 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1578 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1579 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1580 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1581 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1582 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1583 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1584 
1585 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1586 
1587 /* source-level API compatibility */
1588 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1589 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1590 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1591 
1592 /**
1593  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1594  *
1595  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1596  *
1597  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1598  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1599  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1600  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1601  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1602  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1603  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1604  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1605  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1606  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1607  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1608  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1609  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1610  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1611  *	operating channel center frequency.
1612  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1613  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1614  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1615  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1616  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1617  *		this attribute)
1618  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1619  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1620  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1621  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1622  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1623  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1624  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1625  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1626  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1627  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1628  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1629  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1630  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1631  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1632  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1633  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1634  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1635  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1636  *
1637  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1638  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1639  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1640  *
1641  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1642  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1643  *
1644  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1645  *
1646  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1647  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1648  *	keys
1649  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1650  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1651  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1652  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1653  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1654  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1655  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1656  *	default management key
1657  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1658  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1659  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1660  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1661  *
1662  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1663  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1664  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1665  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1666  *
1667  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1668  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1669  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1670  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1671  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1672  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1673  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1674  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1675  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1676  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1677  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1678  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1679  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1680  *
1681  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1682  *	consisting of a nested array.
1683  *
1684  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1685  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1686  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1687  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1688  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1689  * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1690  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1691  *
1692  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1693  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1694  *
1695  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1696  * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1697  * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1698  * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1699  * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1700  * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1701  * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1702  * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1703  * 	to a specific alpha2.
1704  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1705  *	rules.
1706  *
1707  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1708  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1709  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1710  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1711  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1712  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1713  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1714  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1715  *
1716  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1717  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1718  *
1719  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1720  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1721  *	of the interface mode.
1722  *
1723  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1724  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1725  *
1726  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1727  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1728  *
1729  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1730  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1731  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1732  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1733  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1734  *	that can be added to a scan request
1735  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1736  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1737  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1738  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1739  *
1740  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1741  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1742  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1743  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1744  *
1745  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1746  * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1747  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1748  * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1749  *
1750  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1751  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1752  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1753  *
1754  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1755  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1756  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1757  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1758  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1759  *	represented as a u32
1760  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1761  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1762  *
1763  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1764  *	a u32
1765  *
1766  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1767  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1768  * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1769  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1770  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1771  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1772  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1773  * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1774  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1775  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1776  *
1777  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1778  *	cipher suites
1779  *
1780  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1781  *	for other networks on different channels
1782  *
1783  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1784  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1785  *
1786  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1787  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1788  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1789  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1790  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1791  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1792  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1793  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1794  *
1795  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1796  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1797  *
1798  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1799  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1800  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1801  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1802  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1803  *	default in station mode.
1804  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1805  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1806  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1807  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1808  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1809  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1810  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1811  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1812  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1813  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1814  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1815  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1816  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1817  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1818  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1819  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1820  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1821  *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1822  *	frames are not forwared over the control port.
1823  *
1824  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1825  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1826  *
1827  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1828  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1829  *	a local disconnect request.
1830  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1831  *	event (u16)
1832  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1833  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1834  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1835  *
1836  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
1837  *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
1838  *	(an array of u32).
1839  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1840  *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
1841  *	u32).
1842  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1843  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1844  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1845  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1846  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1847  *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1848  *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1849  *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1850  *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1851  *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1852  *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1853  *
1854  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1855  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1856  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1857  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1858  *
1859  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1860  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1861  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1862  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1863  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1864  *
1865  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1866  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1867  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1868  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1869  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1870  *
1871  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1872  *
1873  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1874  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1875  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1876  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1877  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1878  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1879  *	completely from scratch.
1880  *
1881  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1882  *
1883  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1884  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1885  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1886  *
1887  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1888  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1889  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1890  *
1891  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1892  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1893  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1894  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1895  *
1896  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1897  *
1898  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1899  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1900  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1901  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1902  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1903  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1904  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1905  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1906  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1907  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1908  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1909  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1910  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1911  *
1912  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1913  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1914  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1915  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1916  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1917  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1918  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1919  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1920  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1921  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1922  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1923  *
1924  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1925  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1926  *
1927  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1928  *
1929  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1930  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1931  *
1932  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1933  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1934  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1935  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1936  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1937  *
1938  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1939  *	connected to this BSS.
1940  *
1941  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1942  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1943  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1944  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1945  *      for non-automatic settings.
1946  *
1947  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1948  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1949  *
1950  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1951  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1952  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1953  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1954  *
1955  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1956  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1957  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1958  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1959  *	a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not.
1960  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1961  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1962  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not.
1963  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1964  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1965  *
1966  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1967  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1968  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1969  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1970  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
1971  *
1972  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1973  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
1974  *
1975  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1976  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
1977  *
1978  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
1979  *
1980  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
1981  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
1982  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
1983  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
1984  *	nl80211 capability flag.
1985  *
1986  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
1987  *
1988  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
1989  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
1990  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
1991  *
1992  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
1993  *	changed once the mesh is active.
1994  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
1995  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
1996  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
1997  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
1998  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
1999  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
2000  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
2001  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
2002  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
2003  *
2004  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
2005  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
2006  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
2007  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
2008  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
2009  *	triggers.
2010  *
2011  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
2012  *	cycles, in msecs.
2013  *
2014  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
2015  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
2016  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
2017  *	pass-thru filter rules.
2018  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
2019  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
2020  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
2021  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
2022  *	able to ignore them by itself.
2023  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
2024  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
2025  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
2026  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
2027  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
2028  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
2029  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
2030  *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
2031  *
2032  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
2033  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
2034  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2035  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
2036  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
2037  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
2038  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
2039  *
2040  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
2041  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
2042  *
2043  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
2044  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
2045  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
2046  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
2047  *
2048  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
2049  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
2050  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
2051  *
2052  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
2053  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
2054  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
2055  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
2056  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
2057  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
2058  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
2059  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
2060  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
2061  *
2062  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
2063  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
2064  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
2065  *	as AP.
2066  *
2067  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
2068  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
2069  *
2070  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
2071  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
2072  *
2073  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
2074  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
2075  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
2076  *	applications use this attribute.
2077  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
2078  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
2079  *
2080  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
2081  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
2082  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
2083  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
2084  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
2085  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
2086  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
2087  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
2088  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
2089  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
2090  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
2091  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
2092  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
2093  *
2094  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
2095  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
2096  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
2097  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
2098  *
2099  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
2100  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
2101  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
2102  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
2103  *
2104  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
2105  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
2106  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
2107  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
2108  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
2109  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
2110  *
2111  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
2112  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
2113  *	to be filled by the FW.
2114  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
2115  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2116  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2117  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
2118  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2119  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2120  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
2121  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2122  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2123  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2124  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2125  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2126  *      The values that may be configured are:
2127  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
2128  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
2129  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2130  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2131  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
2132  *
2133  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
2134  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
2135  *    to one DFS region.
2136  *
2137  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
2138  *      up to 16 TIDs.
2139  *
2140  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
2141  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
2142  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
2143  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
2144  *	capability to timeout the stations.
2145  *
2146  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2147  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2148  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2149  *
2150  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2151  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2152  *
2153  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2154  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2155  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2156  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2157  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2158  *
2159  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2160  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2161  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2162  *
2163  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2164  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2165  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2166  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2167  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2168  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2169  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2170  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2171  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2172  *	consistent.
2173  *
2174  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2175  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2176  *
2177  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2178  *
2179  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2180  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2181  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2182  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2183  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2184  *	no change is made.
2185  *
2186  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2187  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2188  *
2189  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2190  *	carried in a u32 attribute
2191  *
2192  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2193  *	MAC ACL.
2194  *
2195  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2196  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2197  *	ACL.
2198  *
2199  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2200  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2201  *
2202  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2203  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2204  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2205  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2206  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2207  *
2208  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2209  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2210  *
2211  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2212  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2213  *	and PU-APSD.
2214  *
2215  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2216  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2217  *
2218  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2219  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2220  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2221  *
2222  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2223  *
2224  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2225  *	Element
2226  *
2227  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2228  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2229  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2230  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2231  *
2232  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2233  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2234  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2235  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2236  *
2237  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2238  *
2239  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2240  *	until the channel switch event.
2241  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2242  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2243  *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2244  *	was requested by the AP.
2245  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2246  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2247  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2248  *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2249  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2250  *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2251  *
2252  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2253  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2254  *
2255  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2256  *
2257  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2258  *      operating classes.
2259  *
2260  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2261  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2262  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2263  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2264  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2265  *	IBSS network.
2266  *
2267  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2268  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2269  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2270  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2271  *
2272  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2273  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2274  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2275  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2276  *	u8 attribute.
2277  *
2278  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2279  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2280  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2281  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2282  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2283  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2284  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2285  *
2286  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2287  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2288  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2289  *
2290  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2291  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2292  *
2293  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2294  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2295  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2296  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2297  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2298  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2299  *
2300  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2301  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2302  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2303  *	supported number of csa counters.
2304  *
2305  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2306  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2307  *
2308  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2309  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2310  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2311  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2312  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2313  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2314  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2315  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2316  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2317  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2318  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2319  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2320  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2321  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2322  *	multicast group.
2323  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2324  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2325  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2326  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2327  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2328  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2329  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2330  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2331  *
2332  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2333  *	the TDLS link initiator.
2334  *
2335  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2336  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2337  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2338  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2339  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2340  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2341  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2342  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2343  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2344  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2345  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2346  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2347  *
2348  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2349  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2350  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2351  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2352  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2353  *
2354  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2355  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2356  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2357  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2358  *
2359  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2360  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2361  *
2362  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2363  *
2364  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2365  *
2366  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2367  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2368  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2369  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2370  *
2371  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2372  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2373  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2374  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2375  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2376  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2377  *
2378  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2379  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2380  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2381  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2382  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2383  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2384  *	over all channels.
2385  *
2386  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2387  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2388  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2389  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2390 
2391  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2392  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2393  *
2394  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2395  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2396  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2397  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2398  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2399  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2400  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2401  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2402  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2403  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2404  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2405  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2406  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2407  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2408  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2409  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2410  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2411  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2412  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2413  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2414  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2415  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2416  *
2417  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2418  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2419  *
2420  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2421  *
2422  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2423  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2424  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
2425  *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
2426  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
2427  *	present.
2428  *
2429  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2430  *	groupID for monitor mode.
2431  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2432  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2433  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2434  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2435  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2436  *	each group.
2437  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2438  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2439  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2440  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2441  *	groupID data.
2442  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2443  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2444  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2445  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2446  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2447  *
2448  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2449  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2450  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2451  *	attribute must not be included).
2452  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2453  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2454  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2455  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2456  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2457  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2458  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2459  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2460  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2461  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2462  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2463  *
2464  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2465  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2466  *
2467  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2468  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2469  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2470  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2471  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2472  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2473  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2474  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2475  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2476  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2477  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2478  *	the device will decide what to use.
2479  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2480  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2481  *	attribute.
2482  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2483  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2484  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2485  *	protection.
2486  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2487  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2488  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2489  *
2490  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2491  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2492  *
2493  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2494  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2495  *
2496  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2497  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2498  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2499  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2500  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2501  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2502  *	unnecessary wakeups.
2503  *
2504  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2505  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2506  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2507  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2508  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2509  *
2510  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2511  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2512  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2513  *
2514  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2515  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2516  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2517  *
2518  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2519  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2520  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2521  *
2522  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2523  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2524  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2525  *
2526  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2527  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2528  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2529  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2530  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2531  *
2532  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP
2533  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2534  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2535  *
2536  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2537  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2538  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2539  *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2540  *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2541  *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2542  *	is included as well.
2543  *
2544  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2545  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2546  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2547  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2548  *
2549  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2550  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2551  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2552  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2553  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2554  *
2555  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2556  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2557  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2558  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2559  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2560  *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2561  *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2562  *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2563  *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
2564  *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
2565  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
2566  *
2567  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2568  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2569  *
2570  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2571  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2572  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2573  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2574  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2575  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2576  *      enforced.
2577  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2578  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2579  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2580  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2581  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2582  *
2583  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2584  *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2585  *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2586  *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2587  *
2588  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2589  *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2590  *
2591  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2592  *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2593  *	invalid value.
2594  *
2595  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2596  *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2597  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2598  *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2599  *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2600  *
2601  * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2602  *	scheduler.
2603  *
2604  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2605  *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2606  *	possible values.
2607  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2608  *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2609  *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2610  *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2611  *	or per-station.
2612  *
2613  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2614  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2615  *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2616  *
2617  * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2618  *
2619  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2620  *	functionality.
2621  *
2622  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2623  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2624  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2625  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2626  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2627  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2628  *
2629  * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2630  *	(u16).
2631  *
2632  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2633  *
2634  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2635  *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2636  *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2637  *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2638  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2639  *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2640  *
2641  * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2642  *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2643  *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2644  *	attributes.
2645  *
2646  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2647  *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2648  *
2649  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2650  *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2651  *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2652  *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2653  *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2654  *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2655  *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2656  *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2657  *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2658  *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2659  *
2660  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2661  *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2662  *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2663  *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2664  *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2665  *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2666  *	has expired.
2667  *
2668  *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2669  *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2670  *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2671  *	disassociation is still forced.
2672  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2673  *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2674  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2675  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2676  *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2677  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2678  *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2679  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2680  *
2681  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2682  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2683  *
2684  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2685  *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2686  *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes.
2687  *
2688  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2689  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2690  *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes.
2691  *
2692  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2693  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2694  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2695  *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2696  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2697  *
2698  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2699  *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2700  *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2701  *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2702  *
2703  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2704  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2705  *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2706  *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2707  *
2708  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2709  *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2710  *	is desired.
2711  *
2712  * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
2713  *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
2714  *
2715  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2716  *	until the color switch event.
2717  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
2718  *	switching to
2719  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
2720  *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
2721  *
2722  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
2723  *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
2724  *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
2725  *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
2726  *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
2727  *	parameters.
2728  *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
2729  *
2730  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
2731  *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
2732  *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
2733  *
2734  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
2735  *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
2736  *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
2737  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
2738  *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
2739  *	radar channel.
2740  *
2741  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
2742  *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
2743  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
2744  *
2745  * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
2746  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2747  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2748  *
2749  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
2750  *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
2751  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
2752  *	per-link information and a link ID.
2753  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
2754  *	authenticate/associate.
2755  *
2756  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
2757  *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
2758  *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
2759  *
2760  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
2761  *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
2762  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
2763  *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
2764  *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
2765  *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
2766  *
2767  * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
2768  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
2769  *
2770  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
2771  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2772  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2773  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
2774  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2775  *	the ack TX timestamp.
2776  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
2777  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2778  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2779  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
2780  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2781  *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
2782  * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
2783  *	(re)associations.
2784  *
2785  * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
2786  *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
2787  *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
2788  *	reserved.
2789  *
2790  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS: Maximum number of peers that HW
2791  *	timestamping can be enabled for concurrently (u16), a wiphy attribute.
2792  *	A value of 0xffff indicates setting for all peers (i.e. not specifying
2793  *	an address with %NL80211_CMD_SET_HW_TIMESTAMP) is supported.
2794  * @NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED: Indicates whether HW timestamping should
2795  *	be enabled or not (flag attribute).
2796  *
2797  * @NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS: Optional nested attribute for
2798  *	reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements. This attribute can be used
2799  *	only when NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA is enabled.
2800  *	Userspace is responsible for splitting the RNR into multiple
2801  *	elements such that each element excludes the non-transmitting
2802  *	profiles already included in the MBSSID element
2803  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS) at the same index. Each EMA beacon
2804  *	will be generated by adding MBSSID and RNR elements at the same
2805  *	index. If the userspace includes more RNR elements than number of
2806  *	MBSSID elements then these will be added in every EMA beacon.
2807  *
2808  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2809  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2810  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2811  */
2812 enum nl80211_attrs {
2813 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2814 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2815 
2816 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2817 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2818 
2819 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2820 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2821 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2822 
2823 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2824 
2825 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2826 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2827 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2828 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2829 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2830 
2831 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2832 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2833 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2834 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2835 
2836 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2837 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2838 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2839 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2840 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2841 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2842 
2843 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2844 
2845 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2846 
2847 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2848 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2849 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2850 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2851 
2852 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2853 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2854 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2855 
2856 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2857 
2858 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2859 
2860 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2861 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2862 
2863 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2864 
2865 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2866 
2867 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2868 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2869 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2870 
2871 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2872 
2873 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2874 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2875 
2876 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2877 
2878 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2879 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2880 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2881 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2882 
2883 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2884 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2885 
2886 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2887 
2888 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2889 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2890 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2891 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2892 
2893 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2894 
2895 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2896 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2897 
2898 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2899 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2900 
2901 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2902 
2903 
2904 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2905 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2906 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2907 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2908 
2909 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2910 
2911 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2912 
2913 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2914 
2915 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2916 
2917 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2918 
2919 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2920 
2921 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2922 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2923 
2924 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2925 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2926 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2927 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2928 
2929 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2930 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2931 
2932 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2933 
2934 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2935 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2936 
2937 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
2938 
2939 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
2940 
2941 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
2942 
2943 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
2944 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
2945 
2946 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
2947 
2948 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
2949 
2950 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
2951 
2952 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
2953 
2954 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
2955 
2956 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
2957 
2958 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
2959 
2960 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
2961 
2962 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
2963 
2964 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
2965 
2966 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2967 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
2968 
2969 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
2970 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
2971 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
2972 
2973 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
2974 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
2975 
2976 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
2977 
2978 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
2979 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
2980 
2981 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
2982 
2983 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
2984 
2985 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
2986 
2987 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
2988 
2989 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
2990 
2991 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
2992 
2993 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
2994 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
2995 
2996 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
2997 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
2998 
2999 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
3000 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
3001 
3002 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
3003 
3004 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
3005 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
3006 
3007 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
3008 
3009 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
3010 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
3011 
3012 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
3013 
3014 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
3015 
3016 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
3017 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
3018 
3019 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
3020 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
3021 
3022 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
3023 
3024 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
3025 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
3026 
3027 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
3028 
3029 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
3030 
3031 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
3032 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
3033 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
3034 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
3035 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
3036 
3037 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
3038 
3039 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
3040 
3041 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
3042 
3043 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
3044 
3045 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
3046 
3047 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
3048 
3049 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
3050 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3051 
3052 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
3053 
3054 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
3055 
3056 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
3057 
3058 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
3059 
3060 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
3061 
3062 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
3063 
3064 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
3065 
3066 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
3067 
3068 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
3069 
3070 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
3071 
3072 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
3073 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
3074 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
3075 
3076 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
3077 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
3078 
3079 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
3080 
3081 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
3082 
3083 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
3084 
3085 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
3086 
3087 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
3088 
3089 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
3090 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
3091 
3092 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
3093 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
3094 
3095 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
3096 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
3097 
3098 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
3099 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3100 
3101 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
3102 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
3103 
3104 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
3105 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
3106 
3107 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
3108 
3109 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
3110 
3111 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
3112 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
3113 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
3114 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
3115 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
3116 
3117 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
3118 
3119 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
3120 
3121 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
3122 
3123 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
3124 
3125 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
3126 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
3127 
3128 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
3129 
3130 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
3131 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
3132 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
3133 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
3134 
3135 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
3136 
3137 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
3138 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
3139 
3140 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
3141 
3142 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
3143 
3144 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
3145 
3146 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
3147 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
3148 
3149 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
3150 
3151 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
3152 
3153 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
3154 
3155 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
3156 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
3157 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
3158 
3159 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
3160 
3161 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
3162 
3163 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
3164 
3165 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
3166 
3167 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
3168 
3169 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
3170 
3171 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
3172 
3173 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
3174 
3175 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
3176 
3177 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3178 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
3179 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
3180 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3181 
3182 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
3183 
3184 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
3185 
3186 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
3187 
3188 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
3189 
3190 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
3191 
3192 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
3193 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
3194 
3195 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
3196 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
3197 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
3198 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
3199 
3200 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
3201 
3202 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
3203 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
3204 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
3205 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
3206 
3207 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
3208 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
3209 
3210 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
3211 
3212 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
3213 
3214 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3215 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
3216 
3217 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
3218 
3219 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
3220 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
3221 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
3222 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
3223 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
3224 
3225 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
3226 
3227 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
3228 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
3229 
3230 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
3231 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
3232 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
3233 
3234 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
3235 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
3236 
3237 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
3238 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
3239 
3240 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
3241 
3242 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
3243 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
3244 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3245 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3246 
3247 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3248 
3249 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3250 
3251 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3252 
3253 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3254 
3255 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3256 
3257 	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3258 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3259 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3260 
3261 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3262 
3263 	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3264 
3265 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3266 
3267 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3268 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3269 
3270 	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3271 
3272 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3273 
3274 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3275 
3276 	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3277 
3278 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3279 
3280 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3281 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3282 
3283 	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3284 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3285 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3286 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3287 
3288 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3289 
3290 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3291 
3292 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3293 
3294 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3295 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3296 
3297 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3298 
3299 	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3300 
3301 	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3302 
3303 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3304 
3305 	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
3306 
3307 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
3308 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
3309 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
3310 
3311 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
3312 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
3313 
3314 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
3315 
3316 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
3317 
3318 	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
3319 
3320 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
3321 
3322 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
3323 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
3324 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
3325 
3326 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
3327 
3328 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
3329 
3330 	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
3331 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
3332 
3333 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3334 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3335 	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
3336 
3337 	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
3338 
3339 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_HW_TIMESTAMP_PEERS,
3340 	NL80211_ATTR_HW_TIMESTAMP_ENABLED,
3341 
3342 	NL80211_ATTR_EMA_RNR_ELEMS,
3343 
3344 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3345 
3346 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3347 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3348 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3349 };
3350 
3351 /* source-level API compatibility */
3352 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3353 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3354 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3355 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3356 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3357 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3358 
3359 /*
3360  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3361  * here
3362  */
3363 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3364 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3365 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3366 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3367 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3368 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3369 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3370 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3371 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3372 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3373 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3374 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3375 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3376 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3377 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3378 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3379 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3380 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3381 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3382 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3383 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3384 
3385 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3386 
3387 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3388 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3389 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3390 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3391 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3392 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3393 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3394 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3395 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3396 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3397 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3398 
3399 /*
3400  * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
3401  * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
3402  */
3403 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3404 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
3405 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
3406 
3407 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3408 
3409 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3410 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3411 
3412 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3413 
3414 /**
3415  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3416  *
3417  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3418  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3419  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3420  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3421  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3422  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3423  *	AP type interface.
3424  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3425  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3426  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3427  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3428  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3429  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3430  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3431  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3432  *	commands to create and destroy one
3433  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3434  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3435  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3436  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3437  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3438  *
3439  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3440  * to set the type of an interface.
3441  *
3442  */
3443 enum nl80211_iftype {
3444 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3445 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3446 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3447 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3448 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3449 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3450 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3451 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3452 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3453 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3454 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3455 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3456 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3457 
3458 	/* keep last */
3459 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3460 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3461 };
3462 
3463 /**
3464  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3465  *
3466  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3467  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3468  *
3469  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3470  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3471  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3472  *	with short barker preamble
3473  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3474  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3475  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3476  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3477  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3478  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3479  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3480  *	as errors.)
3481  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3482  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3483  *	previously added station into associated state
3484  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3485  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3486  */
3487 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3488 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3489 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3490 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3491 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3492 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3493 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3494 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3495 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3496 
3497 	/* keep last */
3498 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3499 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3500 };
3501 
3502 /**
3503  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3504  *
3505  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3506  * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3507  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3508  */
3509 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3510 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3511 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3512 
3513 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3514 };
3515 
3516 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3517 
3518 /**
3519  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3520  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3521  * @set: which values to set them to
3522  *
3523  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3524  */
3525 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3526 	__u32 mask;
3527 	__u32 set;
3528 } __attribute__((packed));
3529 
3530 /**
3531  * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3532  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3533  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3534  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3535  */
3536 enum nl80211_he_gi {
3537 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3538 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3539 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3540 };
3541 
3542 /**
3543  * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3544  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec
3545  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec
3546  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec
3547  */
3548 enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3549 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3550 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3551 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3552 };
3553 
3554 /**
3555  * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3556  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3557  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3558  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3559  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3560  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3561  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3562  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3563  */
3564 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3565 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3566 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3567 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3568 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3569 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3570 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3571 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3572 };
3573 
3574 /**
3575  * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
3576  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3577  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3578  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3579  */
3580 enum nl80211_eht_gi {
3581 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
3582 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
3583 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
3584 };
3585 
3586 /**
3587  * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
3588  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3589  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3590  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
3591  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3592  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
3593  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3594  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3595  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
3596  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3597  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
3598  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
3599  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3600  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
3601  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
3602  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
3603  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
3604  */
3605 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
3606 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
3607 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
3608 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
3609 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
3610 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
3611 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
3612 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
3613 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
3614 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
3615 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
3616 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
3617 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3618 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
3619 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
3620 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
3621 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
3622 };
3623 
3624 /**
3625  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3626  *
3627  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3628  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3629  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3630  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3631  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3632  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3633  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3634  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3635  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3636  *
3637  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3638  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3639  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3640  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3641  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3642  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3643  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3644  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3645  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3646  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3647  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3648  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3649  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3650  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3651  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3652  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3653  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3654  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3655  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3656  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3657  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3658  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3659  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3660  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3661  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3662  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3663  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
3664  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
3665  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3666  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
3667  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
3668  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
3669  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
3670  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3671  */
3672 enum nl80211_rate_info {
3673 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3674 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3675 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3676 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3677 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3678 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3679 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3680 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3681 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3682 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3683 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3684 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3685 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3686 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3687 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3688 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3689 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3690 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3691 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
3692 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
3693 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
3694 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
3695 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
3696 
3697 	/* keep last */
3698 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3699 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3700 };
3701 
3702 /**
3703  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3704  *
3705  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3706  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3707  *
3708  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3709  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3710  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3711  *	(flag)
3712  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3713  *	(flag)
3714  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3715  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3716  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3717  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3718  */
3719 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3720 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3721 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3722 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3723 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3724 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3725 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3726 
3727 	/* keep last */
3728 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3729 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3730 };
3731 
3732 /**
3733  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3734  *
3735  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3736  * when getting information about a station.
3737  *
3738  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3739  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3740  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3741  *	(u32, from this station)
3742  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3743  *	(u32, to this station)
3744  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3745  *	(u64, from this station)
3746  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3747  *	(u64, to this station)
3748  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3749  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3750  * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3751  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3752  *	(u32, from this station)
3753  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3754  *	(u32, to this station)
3755  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3756  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3757  *	(u32, to this station)
3758  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3759  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3760  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3761  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3762  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3763  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3764  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3765  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3766  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3767  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3768  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3769  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3770  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3771  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3772  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3773  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3774  *	non-peer STA
3775  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3776  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3777  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3778  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3779  * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
3780  *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3781  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3782  *	(u64)
3783  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3784  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3785  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3786  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3787  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3788  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3789  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3790  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3791  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3792  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3793  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3794  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3795  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3796  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3797  *	(u32, from this station)
3798  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3799  *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3800  *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3801  *	might not be fully accurate.
3802  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3803  *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3804  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3805  *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3806  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3807  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3808  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3809  *	of STA's association
3810  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3811  *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3812  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3813  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3814  */
3815 enum nl80211_sta_info {
3816 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3817 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3818 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3819 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3820 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3821 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3822 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3823 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3824 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3825 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3826 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3827 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3828 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3829 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3830 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3831 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3832 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3833 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3834 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3835 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3836 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3837 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3838 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3839 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3840 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3841 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3842 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3843 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3844 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3845 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3846 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3847 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3848 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3849 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3850 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3851 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3852 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3853 	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3854 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3855 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3856 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3857 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3858 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3859 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3860 
3861 	/* keep last */
3862 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3863 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3864 };
3865 
3866 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3867 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3868 
3869 
3870 /**
3871  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3872  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3873  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3874  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3875  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3876  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3877  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3878  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3879  *	MSDUs (u64)
3880  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3881  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3882  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3883  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3884  */
3885 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3886 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3887 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3888 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3889 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3890 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3891 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3892 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3893 
3894 	/* keep last */
3895 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3896 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3897 };
3898 
3899 /**
3900  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3901  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3902  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3903  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3904  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3905  *      backlogged
3906  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3907  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3908  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
3909  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
3910  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
3911  *      (only for per-phy stats)
3912  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
3913  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
3914  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
3915  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
3916  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3917  */
3918 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
3919 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
3920 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
3921 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
3922 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
3923 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
3924 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
3925 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
3926 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
3927 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
3928 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
3929 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
3930 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
3931 
3932 	/* keep last */
3933 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
3934 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
3935 };
3936 
3937 /**
3938  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
3939  *
3940  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
3941  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
3942  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
3943  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
3944  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
3945  */
3946 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
3947 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
3948 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
3949 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
3950 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
3951 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
3952 };
3953 
3954 /**
3955  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
3956  *
3957  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
3958  * information about a mesh path.
3959  *
3960  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3961  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
3962  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
3963  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
3964  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
3965  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
3966  * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
3967  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
3968  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
3969  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
3970  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
3971  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
3972  *	currently defined
3973  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3974  */
3975 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
3976 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
3977 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
3978 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
3979 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
3980 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
3981 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
3982 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
3983 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
3984 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
3985 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
3986 
3987 	/* keep last */
3988 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3989 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3990 };
3991 
3992 /**
3993  * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
3994  *
3995  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3996  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
3997  *     for each interface type that supports the band data
3998  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
3999  *     capabilities IE
4000  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
4001  *     capabilities IE
4002  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
4003  *     capabilities IE
4004  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
4005  *     defined in HE capabilities IE
4006  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
4007  *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
4008  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
4009  *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
4010  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
4011  *	capabilities element
4012  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
4013  *	capabilities element
4014  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
4015  *	capabilities element
4016  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
4017  *	defined in EHT capabilities element
4018  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4019  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4020  */
4021 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
4022 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
4023 
4024 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
4025 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
4026 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
4027 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
4028 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
4029 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
4030 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
4031 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
4032 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
4033 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
4034 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
4035 
4036 	/* keep last */
4037 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4038 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4039 };
4040 
4041 /**
4042  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
4043  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4044  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
4045  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
4046  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
4047  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
4048  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4049  *	defined in 802.11n
4050  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4051  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
4052  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
4053  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4054  *	defined in 802.11ac
4055  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4056  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
4057  *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
4058  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
4059  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
4060  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
4061  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
4062  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
4063  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
4064  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET: S1G capabilities, supported S1G-MCS and NSS
4065  *	set subfield, as in the S1G information IE, 5 bytes
4066  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA: S1G capabilities information subfield as in the
4067  *	S1G information IE, 10 bytes
4068  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4069  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4070  */
4071 enum nl80211_band_attr {
4072 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
4073 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
4074 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
4075 
4076 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
4077 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
4078 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
4079 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
4080 
4081 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
4082 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
4083 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
4084 
4085 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
4086 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
4087 
4088 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_MCS_NSS_SET,
4089 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_S1G_CAPA,
4090 
4091 	/* keep last */
4092 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4093 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4094 };
4095 
4096 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
4097 
4098 /**
4099  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
4100  *
4101  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4102  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
4103  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
4104  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
4105  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
4106  * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
4107  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
4108  */
4109 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
4110 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
4111 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
4112 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
4113 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
4114 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
4115 
4116 	/* keep last */
4117 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
4118 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
4119 };
4120 
4121 /**
4122  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
4123  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4124  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
4125  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
4126  *	regulatory domain.
4127  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
4128  * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
4129  * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
4130  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
4131  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4132  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
4133  *	(100 * dBm).
4134  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
4135  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
4136  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long
4137  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
4138  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
4139  *	channel as the control channel
4140  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
4141  *	channel as the control channel
4142  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
4143  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
4144  *	this includes 80+80 channels
4145  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
4146  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
4147  *	isn't possible
4148  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4149  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
4150  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
4151  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
4152  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
4153  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
4154  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
4155  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
4156  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
4157  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
4158  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
4159  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
4160  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
4161  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
4162  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
4163  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
4164  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
4165  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
4166  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
4167  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4168  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
4169  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4170  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
4171  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
4172  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
4173  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
4174  *	in current regulatory domain.
4175  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4176  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
4177  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4178  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
4179  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4180  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
4181  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4182  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
4183  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4184  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
4185  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4186  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
4187  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
4188  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
4189  *	in current regulatory domain.
4190  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
4191  *	currently defined
4192  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4193  *
4194  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
4195  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
4196  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
4197  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
4198  */
4199 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
4200 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
4201 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
4202 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
4203 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
4204 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
4205 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
4206 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
4207 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
4208 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
4209 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
4210 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
4211 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
4212 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
4213 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4214 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
4215 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
4216 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
4217 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
4218 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
4219 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
4220 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
4221 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
4222 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
4223 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
4224 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
4225 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
4226 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
4227 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
4228 
4229 	/* keep last */
4230 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4231 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4232 };
4233 
4234 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
4235 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4236 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4237 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4238 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
4239 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4240 
4241 /**
4242  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
4243  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4244  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
4245  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
4246  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
4247  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
4248  *	currently defined
4249  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4250  */
4251 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
4252 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
4253 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
4254 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
4255 
4256 	/* keep last */
4257 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4258 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4259 };
4260 
4261 /**
4262  * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
4263  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
4264  * 	regulatory domain.
4265  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
4266  * 	regulatory domain.
4267  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
4268  * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
4269  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
4270  * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
4271  * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
4272  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
4273  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
4274  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
4275  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
4276  */
4277 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
4278 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
4279 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
4280 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
4281 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
4282 };
4283 
4284 /**
4285  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
4286  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
4287  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
4288  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
4289  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
4290  * 	domain.
4291  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
4292  * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
4293  * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
4294  * 	them to be applied.
4295  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
4296  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
4297  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
4298  *	domain request to be processed.
4299  */
4300 enum nl80211_reg_type {
4301 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
4302 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
4303 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
4304 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
4305 };
4306 
4307 /**
4308  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
4309  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4310  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
4311  * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
4312  * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
4313  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
4314  * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
4315  * 	band edge.
4316  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
4317  * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
4318  * 	band edge.
4319  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
4320  *	frequency range, in KHz.
4321  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
4322  * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
4323  * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
4324  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
4325  * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
4326  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4327  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
4328  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
4329  *	currently defined
4330  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4331  */
4332 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
4333 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
4334 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
4335 
4336 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
4337 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
4338 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
4339 
4340 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
4341 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
4342 
4343 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4344 
4345 	/* keep last */
4346 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4347 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4348 };
4349 
4350 /**
4351  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
4352  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4353  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
4354  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
4355  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
4356  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
4357  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
4358  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
4359  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
4360  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
4361  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
4362  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
4363  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
4364  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
4365  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
4366  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
4367  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
4368  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
4369  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
4370  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
4371  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
4372  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
4373  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the
4374  *	band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in
4375  *	enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a
4376  *	band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one
4377  *	of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the
4378  *	minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated
4379  *	within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such
4380  *	attributes will be nested within this attribute.
4381  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4382  *	attribute number currently defined
4383  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4384  */
4385 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4386 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4387 
4388 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4389 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4390 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4391 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4392 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4393 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI,
4394 
4395 	/* keep last */
4396 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4397 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4398 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4399 };
4400 
4401 /* only for backward compatibility */
4402 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4403 
4404 /**
4405  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4406  *
4407  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4408  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4409  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4410  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4411  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4412  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4413  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4414  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4415  * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4416  * 	beaconing.
4417  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4418  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4419  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4420  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4421  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4422  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4423  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4424  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4425  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4426  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
4427  */
4428 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4429 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
4430 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
4431 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
4432 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
4433 	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
4434 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
4435 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
4436 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
4437 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
4438 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
4439 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
4440 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
4441 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
4442 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
4443 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
4444 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
4445 	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ		= 1<<18,
4446 };
4447 
4448 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4449 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4450 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4451 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4452 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4453 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4454 
4455 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4456 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4457 
4458 /**
4459  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4460  *
4461  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4462  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4463  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4464  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4465  */
4466 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4467 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4468 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4469 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4470 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4471 };
4472 
4473 /**
4474  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4475  *
4476  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4477  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4478  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4479  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4480  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4481  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4482  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4483  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4484  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4485  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4486  *	supported feature.
4487  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4488  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4489  */
4490 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4491 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4492 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4493 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4494 };
4495 
4496 /**
4497  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4498  *
4499  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4500  * when getting information about a survey.
4501  *
4502  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4503  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4504  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4505  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4506  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4507  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4508  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4509  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4510  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4511  *	channel was sensed busy
4512  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4513  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4514  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4515  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4516  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4517  *	(on this channel or globally)
4518  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4519  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4520  *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4521  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4522  *	currently defined
4523  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4524  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4525  */
4526 enum nl80211_survey_info {
4527 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4528 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4529 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4530 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4531 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4532 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4533 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4534 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4535 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4536 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4537 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4538 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4539 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4540 
4541 	/* keep last */
4542 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4543 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4544 };
4545 
4546 /* keep old names for compatibility */
4547 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4548 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4549 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4550 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4551 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4552 
4553 /**
4554  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4555  *
4556  * Monitor configuration flags.
4557  *
4558  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4559  *
4560  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4561  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4562  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4563  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4564  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
4565  *	overrides all other flags.
4566  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4567  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4568  *
4569  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4570  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4571  */
4572 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4573 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4574 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4575 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4576 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4577 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4578 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4579 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4580 
4581 	/* keep last */
4582 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4583 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4584 };
4585 
4586 /**
4587  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4588  *
4589  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4590  *	not known or has not been set yet.
4591  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4592  *	in Awake state all the time.
4593  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4594  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4595  *	neighbor's beacons.
4596  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4597  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4598  *	for neighbor's beacons.
4599  *
4600  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
4601  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
4602  */
4603 
4604 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4605 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4606 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4607 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4608 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4609 
4610 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4611 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4612 };
4613 
4614 /**
4615  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4616  *
4617  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4618  * active.
4619  *
4620  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4621  *
4622  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4623  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4624  *
4625  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4626  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4627  *
4628  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4629  *	millisecond units
4630  *
4631  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4632  *	on this mesh interface
4633  *
4634  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4635  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4636  *	mesh
4637  *
4638  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4639  *	point.
4640  *
4641  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4642  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4643  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4644  *	set.
4645  *
4646  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4647  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4648  *	target)
4649  *
4650  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4651  *	(in milliseconds)
4652  *
4653  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4654  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4655  *
4656  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4657  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4658  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4659  *
4660  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4661  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4662  *	reference element
4663  *
4664  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4665  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4666  *	mesh
4667  *
4668  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4669  *
4670  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4671  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4672  *
4673  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4674  *	root announcements are transmitted.
4675  *
4676  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4677  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4678  *	Announcement frames.
4679  *
4680  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4681  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4682  *	PERR element.
4683  *
4684  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4685  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4686  *
4687  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4688  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4689  *	a peer link.
4690  *
4691  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4692  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4693  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4694  *
4695  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4696  *
4697  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4698  *
4699  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4700  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4701  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4702  *
4703  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4704  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4705  *
4706  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4707  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4708  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4709  *
4710  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4711  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4712  *
4713  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4714  *
4715  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4716  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4717  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4718  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4719  *
4720  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4721  *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4722  *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4723  *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4724  *
4725  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4726  *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4727  *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4728  *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4729  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4730  *
4731  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4732  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4733  *	in the mesh formation field.
4734  *
4735  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4736  */
4737 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4738 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4739 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4740 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4741 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4742 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4743 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4744 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4745 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4746 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4747 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4748 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4749 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4750 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4751 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4752 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4753 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4754 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4755 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4756 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4757 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4758 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4759 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4760 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4761 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4762 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4763 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4764 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4765 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4766 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4767 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4768 	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4769 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4770 
4771 	/* keep last */
4772 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4773 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4774 };
4775 
4776 /**
4777  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4778  *
4779  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4780  * changed while the mesh is active.
4781  *
4782  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4783  *
4784  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4785  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4786  *	default HWMP.
4787  *
4788  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4789  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4790  *	metric.
4791  *
4792  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4793  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4794  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4795  *	metrics in use.
4796  *
4797  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4798  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4799  *
4800  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4801  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4802  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4803  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4804  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4805  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4806  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4807  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4808  *	userspace daemon.
4809  *
4810  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4811  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4812  *	neighbor offset synchronization
4813  *
4814  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4815  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4816  *
4817  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4818  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4819  *	Default is no authentication method required.
4820  *
4821  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4822  *
4823  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4824  */
4825 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4826 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4827 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4828 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4829 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4830 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4831 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
4832 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
4833 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
4834 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
4835 
4836 	/* keep last */
4837 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4838 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4839 };
4840 
4841 /**
4842  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
4843  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
4844  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
4845  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
4846  *	disabled
4847  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
4848  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4849  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
4850  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4851  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
4852  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
4853  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
4854  */
4855 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
4856 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
4857 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
4858 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
4859 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
4860 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
4861 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
4862 
4863 	/* keep last */
4864 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4865 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4866 };
4867 
4868 enum nl80211_ac {
4869 	NL80211_AC_VO,
4870 	NL80211_AC_VI,
4871 	NL80211_AC_BE,
4872 	NL80211_AC_BK,
4873 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
4874 };
4875 
4876 /* backward compat */
4877 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
4878 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
4879 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
4880 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
4881 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
4882 
4883 /**
4884  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
4885  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4886  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
4887  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4888  *	below the control channel
4889  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4890  *	above the control channel
4891  */
4892 enum nl80211_channel_type {
4893 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
4894 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
4895 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
4896 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
4897 };
4898 
4899 /**
4900  * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
4901  *
4902  * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
4903  *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
4904  *
4905  * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
4906  * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
4907  *
4908  * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
4909  *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
4910  * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
4911  *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
4912  *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
4913  */
4914 enum nl80211_key_mode {
4915 	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
4916 	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
4917 	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
4918 };
4919 
4920 /**
4921  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
4922  *
4923  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
4924  * attribute.
4925  *
4926  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4927  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
4928  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4929  *	attribute must be provided as well
4930  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4931  *	attribute must be provided as well
4932  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4933  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
4934  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4935  *	attribute must be provided as well
4936  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
4937  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
4938  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
4939  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
4940  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
4941  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
4942  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
4943  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4944  *	attribute must be provided as well
4945  */
4946 enum nl80211_chan_width {
4947 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
4948 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4949 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
4950 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
4951 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
4952 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
4953 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4954 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4955 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
4956 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
4957 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
4958 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
4959 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
4960 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
4961 };
4962 
4963 /**
4964  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
4965  *
4966  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
4967  *
4968  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
4969  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
4970  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
4971  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
4972  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
4973  */
4974 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
4975 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4976 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4977 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4978 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
4979 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
4980 };
4981 
4982 /**
4983  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
4984  *
4985  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
4986  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
4987  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
4988  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
4989  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
4990  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
4991  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
4992  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
4993  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
4994  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
4995  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
4996  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
4997  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
4998  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
4999  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
5000  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
5001  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
5002  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
5003  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
5004  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
5005  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
5006  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
5007  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
5008  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
5009  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
5010  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
5011  *	yet been received
5012  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
5013  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width)
5014  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
5015  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
5016  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
5017  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
5018  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
5019  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
5020  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
5021  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
5022  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
5023  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
5024  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
5025  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
5026  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
5027  *	is set.
5028  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
5029  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
5030  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
5031  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
5032  * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
5033  * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
5034  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
5035  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
5036  */
5037 enum nl80211_bss {
5038 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
5039 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
5040 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
5041 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
5042 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
5043 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
5044 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
5045 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
5046 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
5047 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
5048 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
5049 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
5050 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
5051 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
5052 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
5053 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
5054 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
5055 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5056 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
5057 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
5058 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
5059 	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
5060 	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
5061 
5062 	/* keep last */
5063 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
5064 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5065 };
5066 
5067 /**
5068  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
5069  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
5070  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
5071  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
5072  *	a given BSS.
5073  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
5074  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
5075  *
5076  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
5077  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
5078  */
5079 enum nl80211_bss_status {
5080 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
5081 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
5082 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
5083 };
5084 
5085 /**
5086  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
5087  *
5088  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
5089  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
5090  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
5091  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
5092  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
5093  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
5094  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
5095  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
5096  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
5097  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
5098  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
5099  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
5100  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
5101  */
5102 enum nl80211_auth_type {
5103 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
5104 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
5105 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
5106 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
5107 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
5108 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
5109 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
5110 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
5111 
5112 	/* keep last */
5113 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
5114 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
5115 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
5116 };
5117 
5118 /**
5119  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
5120  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
5121  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
5122  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
5123  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
5124  */
5125 enum nl80211_key_type {
5126 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
5127 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
5128 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
5129 
5130 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
5131 };
5132 
5133 /**
5134  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
5135  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
5136  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
5137  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
5138  */
5139 enum nl80211_mfp {
5140 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
5141 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
5142 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5143 };
5144 
5145 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
5146 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
5147 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
5148 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
5149 };
5150 
5151 /**
5152  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
5153  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
5154  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
5155  *	unicast key
5156  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
5157  *	multicast key
5158  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
5159  */
5160 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
5161 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
5162 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
5163 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
5164 
5165 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
5166 };
5167 
5168 /**
5169  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
5170  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
5171  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
5172  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
5173  *	keys
5174  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
5175  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
5176  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
5177  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
5178  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
5179  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
5180  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
5181  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
5182  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
5183  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
5184  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
5185  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
5186  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
5187  * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
5188  *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
5189  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
5190  *
5191  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
5192  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
5193  */
5194 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
5195 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
5196 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
5197 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
5198 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
5199 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
5200 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
5201 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
5202 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
5203 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
5204 	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
5205 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
5206 
5207 	/* keep last */
5208 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
5209 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
5210 };
5211 
5212 /**
5213  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
5214  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
5215  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5216  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
5217  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
5218  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
5219  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5220  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
5221  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5222  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
5223  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
5224  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5225  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
5226  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
5227  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
5228  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
5229  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
5230  */
5231 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
5232 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
5233 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
5234 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
5235 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
5236 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
5237 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
5238 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
5239 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
5240 
5241 	/* keep last */
5242 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
5243 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
5244 };
5245 
5246 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
5247 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
5248 
5249 /**
5250  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5251  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5252  */
5253 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
5254 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
5255 };
5256 
5257 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
5258 /**
5259  * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5260  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5261  */
5262 struct nl80211_txrate_he {
5263 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
5264 };
5265 
5266 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
5267 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
5268 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
5269 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
5270 };
5271 
5272 /**
5273  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
5274  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
5275  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
5276  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
5277  * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
5278  * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
5279  * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
5280  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
5281  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
5282  */
5283 enum nl80211_band {
5284 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
5285 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
5286 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
5287 	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
5288 	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
5289 	NL80211_BAND_LC,
5290 
5291 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
5292 };
5293 
5294 /**
5295  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
5296  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
5297  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
5298  */
5299 enum nl80211_ps_state {
5300 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
5301 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
5302 };
5303 
5304 /**
5305  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
5306  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
5307  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
5308  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
5309  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
5310  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
5311  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
5312  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
5313  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
5314  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
5315  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
5316  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
5317  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
5318  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
5319  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
5320  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
5321  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
5322  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
5323  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
5324  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
5325  *	checked.
5326  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
5327  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
5328  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
5329  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
5330  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
5331  *	loss event
5332  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
5333  *	RSSI threshold event.
5334  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
5335  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
5336  */
5337 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
5338 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
5339 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
5340 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
5341 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
5342 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
5343 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
5344 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
5345 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
5346 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5347 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
5348 
5349 	/* keep last */
5350 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
5351 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
5352 };
5353 
5354 /**
5355  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
5356  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
5357  *      configured threshold
5358  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
5359  *      configured threshold
5360  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
5361  */
5362 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
5363 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
5364 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
5365 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5366 };
5367 
5368 
5369 /**
5370  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
5371  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
5372  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
5373  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
5374  */
5375 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
5376 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
5377 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
5378 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
5379 };
5380 
5381 /**
5382  * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
5383  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
5384  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
5385  */
5386 enum nl80211_tid_config {
5387 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
5388 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
5389 };
5390 
5391 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5392  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5393  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5394  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5395  */
5396 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5397 	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5398 	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5399 	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5400 };
5401 
5402 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5403  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5404  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5405  *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5406  *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5407  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5408  *	per peer instead.
5409  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates
5410  *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5411  *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5412  *	should be left untouched.
5413  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5414  *	Its type is u16.
5415  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5416  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5417  *	Its type is u8.
5418  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5419  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5420  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5421  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5422  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5423  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5424  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5425  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5426  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5427  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5428  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5429  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5430  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5431  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5432  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5433  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5434  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5435  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5436  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5437  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5438  *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5439  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5440  *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5441  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5442  *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5443  *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5444  *	station.
5445  */
5446 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5447 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5448 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5449 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5450 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5451 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5452 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5453 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5454 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5455 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5456 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5457 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5458 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5459 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5460 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5461 
5462 	/* keep last */
5463 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5464 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5465 };
5466 
5467 /**
5468  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5469  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5470  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5471  *	a zero bit are ignored
5472  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5473  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5474  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5475  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5476  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5477  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5478  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5479  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5480  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5481  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5482  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5483  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5484  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5485  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5486  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5487  */
5488 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5489 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5490 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5491 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5492 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5493 
5494 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5495 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5496 };
5497 
5498 /**
5499  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5500  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5501  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5502  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5503  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5504  *
5505  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5506  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5507  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5508  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5509  * by the kernel to userspace.
5510  */
5511 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5512 	__u32 max_patterns;
5513 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5514 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5515 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5516 } __attribute__((packed));
5517 
5518 /* only for backward compatibility */
5519 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5520 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5521 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5522 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5523 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5524 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5525 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5526 
5527 /**
5528  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5529  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5530  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5531  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5532  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5533  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5534  *	any others are even supported by the device.
5535  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5536  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5537  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5538  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5539  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5540  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5541  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5542  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5543  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5544  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5545  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5546  *
5547  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5548  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5549  *
5550  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5551  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5552  *	to the kernel when configuring.
5553  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5554  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5555  *	by the device (flag)
5556  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5557  *	done by the device) (flag)
5558  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5559  *	packet (flag)
5560  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5561  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5562  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5563  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5564  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5565  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5566  *	attribute contains the original length.
5567  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5568  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5569  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5570  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5571  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5572  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5573  *	contains the original length.
5574  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5575  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5576  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5577  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5578  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5579  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5580  *	the TCP connection.
5581  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5582  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5583  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5584  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5585  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5586  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5587  *	service
5588  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5589  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5590  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5591  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5592  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5593  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5594  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5595  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5596  *	supported by the driver (u32).
5597  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5598  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5599  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5600  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5601  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5602  *	occurred.
5603  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5604  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5605  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5606  *	these attributes must be present.  If
5607  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5608  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5609  *	channel.
5610  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5611  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5612  *
5613  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5614  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5615  */
5616 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5617 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5618 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5619 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5620 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5621 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5622 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5623 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5624 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5625 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5626 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5627 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5628 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5629 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5630 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5631 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5632 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5633 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5634 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5635 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5636 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5637 
5638 	/* keep last */
5639 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5640 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5641 };
5642 
5643 /**
5644  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5645  *
5646  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5647  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5648  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5649  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5650  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5651  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5652  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5653  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5654  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5655  *
5656  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5657  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5658  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5659  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5660  * also woken up.
5661  *
5662  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5663  * response packets might not go through correctly.
5664  */
5665 
5666 /**
5667  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5668  * @start: starting value
5669  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5670  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5671  *
5672  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5673  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5674  * in little endian.
5675  */
5676 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5677 	__u32 start, offset, len;
5678 };
5679 
5680 /**
5681  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5682  * @offset: offset of token in packet
5683  * @len: length of each token
5684  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5685  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5686  */
5687 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5688 	__u32 offset, len;
5689 	__u8 token_stream[];
5690 };
5691 
5692 /**
5693  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5694  * @min_len: minimum token length
5695  * @max_len: maximum token length
5696  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5697  */
5698 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5699 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5700 };
5701 
5702 /**
5703  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5704  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5705  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5706  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5707  *	(in network byte order)
5708  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5709  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5710  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5711  *	might require ARP querying.
5712  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5713  *	socket and port will be allocated
5714  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5715  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5716  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5717  *	of the data payload.
5718  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5719  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5720  *	advertising it is just a flag
5721  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5722  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5723  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5724  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5725  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5726  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5727  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5728  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5729  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5730  *	but on the TCP payload only.
5731  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5732  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5733  */
5734 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5735 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5736 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5737 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5738 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5739 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5740 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5741 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5742 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5743 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5744 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5745 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5746 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5747 
5748 	/* keep last */
5749 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5750 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5751 };
5752 
5753 /**
5754  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5755  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5756  * @pat: packet pattern support information
5757  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5758  *
5759  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5760  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5761  */
5762 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5763 	__u32 max_rules;
5764 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5765 	__u32 max_delay;
5766 } __attribute__((packed));
5767 
5768 /**
5769  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5770  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5771  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5772  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5773  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5774  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5775  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5776  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5777  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5778  */
5779 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5780 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5781 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5782 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5783 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5784 
5785 	/* keep last */
5786 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5787 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5788 };
5789 
5790 /**
5791  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
5792  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns
5793  *	in a rule are matched.
5794  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5795  *	in a rule are not matched.
5796  */
5797 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
5798 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
5799 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
5800 };
5801 
5802 /**
5803  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
5804  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5805  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
5806  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
5807  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
5808  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
5809  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
5810  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
5811  */
5812 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
5813 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
5814 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
5815 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
5816 
5817 	/* keep last */
5818 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
5819 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
5820 };
5821 
5822 /**
5823  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
5824  *
5825  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5826  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
5827  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
5828  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
5829  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
5830  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
5831  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
5832  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
5833  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
5834  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
5835  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
5836  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
5837  *	different channels may be used within this group.
5838  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5839  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
5840  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5841  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
5842  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
5843  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
5844  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
5845  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
5846  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
5847  *
5848  * Examples:
5849  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
5850  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
5851  *
5852  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
5853  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
5854  *
5855  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
5856  *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
5857  *
5858  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
5859  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
5860  *
5861  * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
5862  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
5863  * that any of these groups must match.
5864  *
5865  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
5866  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
5867  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
5868  * interface type, the following group always exists:
5869  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
5870  */
5871 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
5872 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
5873 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
5874 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
5875 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
5876 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
5877 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
5878 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
5879 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
5880 
5881 	/* keep last */
5882 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
5883 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
5884 };
5885 
5886 
5887 /**
5888  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
5889  *
5890  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
5891  *	state of non existent mesh peer links
5892  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
5893  *	this mesh peer
5894  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
5895  *	from this mesh peer
5896  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
5897  *	received from this mesh peer
5898  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
5899  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
5900  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
5901  *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
5902  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
5903  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
5904  */
5905 enum nl80211_plink_state {
5906 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
5907 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
5908 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
5909 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
5910 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
5911 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
5912 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
5913 
5914 	/* keep last */
5915 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
5916 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
5917 };
5918 
5919 /**
5920  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
5921  *
5922  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
5923  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
5924  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
5925  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
5926  */
5927 enum plink_actions {
5928 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
5929 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
5930 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
5931 
5932 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
5933 };
5934 
5935 
5936 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
5937 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
5938 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
5939 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
5940 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
5941 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
5942 
5943 /**
5944  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
5945  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5946  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
5947  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
5948  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
5949  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
5950  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
5951  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
5952  */
5953 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
5954 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
5955 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
5956 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
5957 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
5958 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
5959 
5960 	/* keep last */
5961 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
5962 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
5963 };
5964 
5965 /**
5966  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
5967  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
5968  *	Beacon frames)
5969  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
5970  *	in Beacon frames
5971  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
5972  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
5973  */
5974 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
5975 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
5976 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
5977 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
5978 };
5979 
5980 /**
5981  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
5982  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5983  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
5984  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
5985  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
5986  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
5987  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
5988  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
5989  */
5990 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
5991 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
5992 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
5993 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
5994 
5995 	/* keep last */
5996 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
5997 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
5998 };
5999 
6000 /**
6001  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
6002  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
6003  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
6004  *	priority)
6005  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
6006  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
6007  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
6008  *	(internal)
6009  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
6010  *	(internal)
6011  */
6012 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
6013 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
6014 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
6015 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
6016 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
6017 
6018 	/* keep last */
6019 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
6020 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
6021 };
6022 
6023 /**
6024  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
6025  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
6026  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
6027  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
6028  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
6029  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
6030  */
6031 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
6032 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
6033 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
6034 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
6035 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
6036 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
6037 };
6038 
6039 /**
6040  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
6041  * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
6042  *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
6043  *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
6044  */
6045 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
6046 	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
6047 };
6048 
6049 /**
6050  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
6051  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
6052  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
6053  *	socket option.
6054  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
6055  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
6056  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
6057  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
6058  *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
6059  *	cellular base stations.
6060  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
6061  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
6062  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
6063  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
6064  *	mode
6065  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
6066  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
6067  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
6068  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
6069  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
6070  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
6071  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
6072  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
6073  *	setting
6074  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
6075  *	powersave
6076  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
6077  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
6078  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
6079  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
6080  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
6081  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
6082  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
6083  *	states using station flags.
6084  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
6085  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
6086  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
6087  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
6088  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
6089  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
6090  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
6091  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
6092  *	still generated by the driver.
6093  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
6094  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
6095  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
6096  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
6097  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
6098  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
6099  *	lifetime of a BSS.
6100  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
6101  *	Set IE to probe requests.
6102  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
6103  *	to probe requests.
6104  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
6105  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
6106  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
6107  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
6108  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
6109  *	Measurement Report action frame.
6110  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
6111  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
6112  *	to enable dynack.
6113  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
6114  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6115  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
6116  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
6117  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6118  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
6119  *	rts/cts handshake.
6120  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
6121  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
6122  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
6123  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
6124  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
6125  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
6126  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
6127  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
6128  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
6129  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6130  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
6131  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
6132  *	address mask/value will be used.
6133  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
6134  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
6135  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6136  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6137  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6138  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
6139  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6140  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6141  */
6142 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
6143 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
6144 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
6145 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
6146 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
6147 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
6148 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
6149 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
6150 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
6151 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
6152 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
6153 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
6154 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
6155 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
6156 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
6157 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
6158 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
6159 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
6160 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
6161 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
6162 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
6163 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
6164 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
6165 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
6166 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
6167 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
6168 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
6169 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
6170 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
6171 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
6172 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
6173 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
6174 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
6175 };
6176 
6177 /**
6178  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
6179  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
6180  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
6181  *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
6182  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
6183  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
6184  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized.
6185  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
6186  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
6187  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
6188  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
6189  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
6190  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
6191  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
6192  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
6193  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6194  *	(if available).
6195  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
6196  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the
6197  *	BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6198  *	(if available).
6199  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
6200  *	channel dwell time.
6201  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
6202  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate.
6203  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
6204  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
6205  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
6206  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
6207  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
6208  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
6209  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
6210  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
6211  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
6212  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
6213  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
6214  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
6215  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
6216  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
6217  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
6218  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
6219  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
6220  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
6221  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6222  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
6223  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
6224  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
6225  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
6226  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
6227  *	be supported.
6228  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
6229  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
6230  *	actual dwell time.
6231  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
6232  *	response
6233  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
6234  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
6235  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
6236  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
6237  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
6238  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
6239  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
6240  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
6241  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
6242  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
6243  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
6244  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
6245  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
6246  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
6247  *	"radar detected" event.
6248  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
6249  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
6250  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
6251  *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
6252  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
6253  *      TXQs.
6254  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
6255  *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
6256  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
6257  *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
6258  *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
6259  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
6260  *	timing measurement responder role.
6261  *
6262  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
6263  *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
6264  *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
6265  *      freeze the connection.
6266  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
6267  *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
6268  *
6269  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
6270  *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
6271  *	scheduling.
6272  *
6273  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
6274  *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
6275  *
6276  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports
6277  *	filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds.
6278  *
6279  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
6280  *	to a station.
6281  *
6282  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
6283  *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
6284  *
6285  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
6286  *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
6287  *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
6288  *
6289  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
6290  *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
6291  *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
6292  *
6293  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
6294  *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
6295  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
6296  *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
6297  *
6298  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
6299  *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
6300  *	handled as ordinary data frames.
6301  *
6302  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
6303  *
6304  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
6305  *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
6306  *
6307  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
6308  *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
6309  *
6310  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
6311  *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
6312  *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
6313  *	included in the scan request.
6314  *
6315  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
6316  *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
6317  *
6318  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
6319  *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
6320  *
6321  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6322  *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
6323  *	command).
6324  *
6325  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
6326  *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
6327  *
6328  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
6329  *	frames transmission
6330  *
6331  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
6332  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
6333  *
6334  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
6335  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
6336  *
6337  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
6338  *      exchange protocol.
6339  *
6340  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
6341  *      exchange protocol.
6342  *
6343  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
6344  *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
6345  *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
6346  *
6347  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
6348  *	detection and change announcemnts.
6349  *
6350  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
6351  *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
6352  *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
6353  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
6354  *
6355  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
6356  *	detection.
6357  *
6358  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
6359  *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
6360  *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
6361  *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
6362  *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
6363  *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
6364  *	in progress, and no active connections.
6365  *
6366  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
6367  *
6368  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
6369  *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
6370  *
6371  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA: Device supports randomized TA
6372  *	in authentication and deauthentication frames sent to unassociated peer
6373  *	using @NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
6374  *
6375  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
6376  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
6377  */
6378 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
6379 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
6380 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
6381 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
6382 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
6383 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
6384 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
6385 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
6386 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
6387 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
6388 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
6389 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
6390 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
6391 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
6392 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
6393 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
6394 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
6395 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
6396 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
6397 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6398 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
6399 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
6400 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
6401 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
6402 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
6403 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
6404 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
6405 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
6406 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6407 	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
6408 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6409 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
6410 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
6411 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
6412 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
6413 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
6414 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
6415 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
6416 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD,
6417 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
6418 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
6419 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
6420 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
6421 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6422 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6423 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6424 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6425 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6426 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6427 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6428 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6429 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6430 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6431 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6432 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6433 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6434 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6435 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6436 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6437 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6438 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6439 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
6440 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
6441 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
6442 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
6443 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
6444 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
6445 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AUTH_AND_DEAUTH_RANDOM_TA,
6446 
6447 	/* add new features before the definition below */
6448 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6449 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6450 };
6451 
6452 /**
6453  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6454  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6455  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6456  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6457  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6458  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6459  *	to the host.
6460  *
6461  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6462  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6463  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6464  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6465  */
6466 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6467 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6468 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6469 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6470 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6471 };
6472 
6473 /**
6474  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6475  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6476  *	handled by the AP is reached.
6477  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6478  */
6479 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6480 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6481 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6482 };
6483 
6484 /**
6485  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6486  *
6487  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6488  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6489  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6490  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6491  */
6492 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6493 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6494 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6495 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6496 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6497 };
6498 
6499 /**
6500  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6501  *
6502  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6503  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6504  * requests.
6505  *
6506  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6507  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6508  * one of them can be used in the request.
6509  *
6510  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6511  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6512  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6513  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6514  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6515  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6516  *	when really needed
6517  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6518  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6519  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6520  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6521  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6522  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6523  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6524  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6525  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6526  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6527  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6528  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6529  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6530  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6531  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6532  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6533  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6534  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6535  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6536  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6537  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6538  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6539  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6540  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6541  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6542  *	impacted with this flag.
6543  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6544  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6545  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6546  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6547  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6548  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6549  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6550  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6551  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6552  *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6553  *	possible.
6554  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6555  *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6556  *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6557  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6558  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6559  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6560  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for collocated APs reported by
6561  *	2.4/5 GHz APs. When the flag is set, the scan logic will use the
6562  *	information from the RNR element found in beacons/probe responses
6563  *	received on the 2.4/5 GHz channels to actively scan only the 6GHz
6564  *	channels on which APs are expected to be found. Note that when not set,
6565  *	the scan logic would scan all 6GHz channels, but since transmission of
6566  *	probe requests on non PSC channels is limited, it is highly likely that
6567  *	these channels would passively be scanned. Also note that when the flag
6568  *	is set, in addition to the colocated APs, PSC channels would also be
6569  *	scanned if the user space has asked for it.
6570  */
6571 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6572 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6573 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6574 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6575 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6576 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6577 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6578 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6579 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6580 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6581 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6582 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6583 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6584 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6585 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6586 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6587 };
6588 
6589 /**
6590  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6591  *
6592  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6593  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6594  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6595  *
6596  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6597  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6598  *	in ACL to authenticate.
6599  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6600  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6601  */
6602 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6603 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6604 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6605 };
6606 
6607 /**
6608  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6609  *
6610  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6611  *
6612  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6613  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6614  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6615  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6616  */
6617 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6618 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6619 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6620 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6621 
6622 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6623 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6624 };
6625 
6626 /**
6627  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6628  *
6629  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6630  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6631  *
6632  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6633  *	now unusable.
6634  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6635  *	the channel is now available.
6636  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6637  *	change to the channel status.
6638  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6639  *	over, channel becomes usable.
6640  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6641  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6642  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6643  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6644  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6645  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6646  */
6647 enum nl80211_radar_event {
6648 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6649 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6650 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6651 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6652 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6653 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6654 };
6655 
6656 /**
6657  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6658  *
6659  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6660  *
6661  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6662  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6663  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6664  *	is therefore marked as not available.
6665  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6666  */
6667 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6668 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6669 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6670 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6671 };
6672 
6673 /**
6674  * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6675  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6676  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6677  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6678  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6679  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6680  */
6681 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6682 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6683 };
6684 
6685 /**
6686  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6687  *
6688  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6689  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6690  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6691  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6692  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6693  */
6694 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6695 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6696 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6697 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6698 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6699 	/* add other protocols before this one */
6700 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6701 };
6702 
6703 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6704 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6705 
6706 /**
6707  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6708  *
6709  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6710  *
6711  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6712  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6713  *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6714  *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6715  *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6716  */
6717 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6718 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6719 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6720 };
6721 
6722 /*
6723  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6724  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6725  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6726  */
6727 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6728 
6729 /**
6730  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6731  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6732  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6733  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6734  *	added to this file when needed.
6735  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6736  */
6737 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6738 	__u32 vendor_id;
6739 	__u32 subcmd;
6740 };
6741 
6742 /**
6743  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6744  *
6745  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6746  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6747  *
6748  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6749  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6750  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
6751  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
6752  */
6753 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
6754 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
6755 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
6756 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
6757 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
6758 };
6759 
6760 /**
6761  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
6762  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6763  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
6764  *	seconds (u32).
6765  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
6766  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
6767  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
6768  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
6769  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
6770  *	currently defined
6771  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
6772  */
6773 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
6774 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
6775 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
6776 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
6777 
6778 	/* keep last */
6779 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
6780 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
6781 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
6782 };
6783 
6784 /**
6785  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
6786  *
6787  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
6788  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
6789  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
6790  */
6791 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
6792 	__u8 band;
6793 	__s8 delta;
6794 } __attribute__((packed));
6795 
6796 /**
6797  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
6798  *
6799  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
6800  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
6801  *	is requested.
6802  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
6803  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
6804  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
6805  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
6806  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
6807  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
6808  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
6809  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
6810  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
6811  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
6812  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
6813  *
6814  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
6815  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
6816  * which the driver shall use.
6817  */
6818 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
6819 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
6820 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
6821 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
6822 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
6823 
6824 	/* keep last */
6825 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
6826 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
6827 };
6828 
6829 /**
6830  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
6831  *
6832  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
6833  *
6834  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
6835  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
6836  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
6837  */
6838 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
6839 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
6840 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
6841 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
6842 
6843 	/* keep last */
6844 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
6845 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
6846 };
6847 
6848 /**
6849  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
6850  *
6851  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
6852  *
6853  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
6854  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
6855  */
6856 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
6857 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
6858 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
6859 };
6860 
6861 /**
6862  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
6863  *
6864  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
6865  *
6866  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
6867  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
6868  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
6869  */
6870 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
6871 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
6872 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
6873 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
6874 };
6875 
6876 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
6877 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
6878 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
6879 
6880 /**
6881  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
6882  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
6883  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
6884  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
6885  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
6886  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
6887  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
6888  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
6889  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
6890  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
6891  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
6892  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
6893  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
6894  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
6895  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
6896  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
6897  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
6898  *	The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
6899  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
6900  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
6901  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
6902  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
6903  *	This is a flag.
6904  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
6905  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
6906  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
6907  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
6908  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
6909  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
6910  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
6911  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6912  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
6913  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6914  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
6915  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
6916  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
6917  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
6918  *
6919  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
6920  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
6921  */
6922 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
6923 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
6924 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
6925 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
6926 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
6927 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
6928 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
6929 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
6930 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
6931 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
6932 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
6933 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
6934 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
6935 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
6936 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
6937 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
6938 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
6939 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
6940 
6941 	/* keep last */
6942 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
6943 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
6944 };
6945 
6946 /**
6947  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
6948  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
6949  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
6950  *	This is a flag.
6951  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
6952  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
6953  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
6954  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
6955  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
6956  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
6957  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
6958  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
6959  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
6960  */
6961 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
6962 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
6963 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
6964 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
6965 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
6966 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
6967 
6968 	/* keep last */
6969 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
6970 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
6971 };
6972 
6973 /**
6974  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
6975  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
6976  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
6977  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
6978  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6979  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
6980  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
6981  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6982  *
6983  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
6984  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
6985  */
6986 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
6987 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
6988 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
6989 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
6990 
6991 	/* keep last */
6992 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
6993 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
6994 };
6995 
6996 /**
6997  * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
6998  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
6999  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
7000  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
7001  */
7002 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
7003 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
7004 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
7005 };
7006 
7007 /**
7008  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
7009  *	responder attributes
7010  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7011  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
7012  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
7013  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
7014  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7015  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element
7016  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
7017  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
7018  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7019  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
7020  */
7021 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
7022 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7023 
7024 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
7025 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7026 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7027 
7028 	/* keep last */
7029 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7030 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7031 };
7032 
7033 /*
7034  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
7035  *
7036  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
7037  * when getting FTM responder statistics.
7038  *
7039  * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
7040  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
7041  *	were ssfully answered (u32)
7042  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
7043  *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
7044  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
7045  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
7046  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
7047  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
7048  *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
7049  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
7050  *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
7051  *	phase with the responder (u32)
7052  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
7053  *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
7054  *	FTM slot (u32)
7055  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
7056  *	scheduled window (u32)
7057  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
7058  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
7059  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
7060  */
7061 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
7062 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
7063 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
7064 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
7065 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
7066 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
7067 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
7068 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
7069 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7070 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
7071 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7072 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
7073 
7074 	/* keep last */
7075 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
7076 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
7077 };
7078 
7079 /**
7080  * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
7081  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
7082  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
7083  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
7084  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
7085  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
7086  */
7087 enum nl80211_preamble {
7088 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
7089 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
7090 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
7091 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
7092 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
7093 };
7094 
7095 /**
7096  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
7097  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
7098  *	these numbers also for attributes
7099  *
7100  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
7101  *
7102  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
7103  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
7104  */
7105 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
7106 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
7107 
7108 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
7109 
7110 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
7111 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
7112 };
7113 
7114 /**
7115  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
7116  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
7117  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
7118  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
7119  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
7120  *	reason may be available in the response data
7121  */
7122 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
7123 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
7124 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
7125 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
7126 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
7127 };
7128 
7129 /**
7130  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
7131  * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7132  *
7133  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7134  *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
7135  *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
7136  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
7137  *	(flag attribute)
7138  *
7139  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
7140  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7141  */
7142 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
7143 	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7144 
7145 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
7146 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
7147 
7148 	/* keep last */
7149 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
7150 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
7151 };
7152 
7153 /**
7154  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
7155  * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7156  *
7157  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7158  *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
7159  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
7160  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
7161  *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
7162  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
7163  *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
7164  *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
7165  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
7166  *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
7167  *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
7168  *	(u64, usec)
7169  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
7170  *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
7171  *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
7172  *	result.
7173  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
7174  *
7175  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
7176  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7177  */
7178 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
7179 	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7180 
7181 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
7182 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
7183 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
7184 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
7185 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
7186 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7187 
7188 	/* keep last */
7189 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
7190 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
7191 };
7192 
7193 /**
7194  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
7195  * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7196  *
7197  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
7198  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
7199  *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
7200  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7201  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7202  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
7203  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7204  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7205  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
7206  *
7207  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
7208  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7209  */
7210 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
7211 	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
7212 
7213 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
7214 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
7215 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
7216 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
7217 
7218 	/* keep last */
7219 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
7220 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
7221 };
7222 
7223 /**
7224  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
7225  * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7226  *
7227  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
7228  *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
7229  *	measurements can be done with in a single request
7230  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
7231  *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
7232  *	measurement results
7233  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
7234  *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
7235  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
7236  *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
7237  *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
7238  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
7239  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
7240  *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
7241  *	sub-attributes taken from
7242  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
7243  *
7244  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
7245  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7246  */
7247 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
7248 	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
7249 
7250 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
7251 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
7252 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
7253 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
7254 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
7255 
7256 	/* keep last */
7257 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
7258 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
7259 };
7260 
7261 /**
7262  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
7263  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7264  *
7265  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
7266  *	is supported
7267  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
7268  *	mode is supported
7269  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
7270  *	data can be requested during the measurement
7271  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
7272  *	location data can be requested during the measurement
7273  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
7274  *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
7275  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
7276  *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
7277  *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
7278  *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
7279  *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
7280  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
7281  *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
7282  *	is valid)
7283  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
7284  *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
7285  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
7286  *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7287  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
7288  *	if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7289  *
7290  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
7291  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7292  */
7293 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
7294 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
7295 
7296 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
7297 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
7298 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
7299 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
7300 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
7301 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
7302 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
7303 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7304 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7305 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7306 
7307 	/* keep last */
7308 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
7309 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
7310 };
7311 
7312 /**
7313  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
7314  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7315  *
7316  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
7317  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
7318  *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
7319  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
7320  *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
7321  *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7322  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
7323  *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
7324  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
7325  *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
7326  *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7327  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
7328  *	requested per burst
7329  *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
7330  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
7331  *	(u8, default 3)
7332  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
7333  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
7334  *	(flag)
7335  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
7336  *	measurement (flag).
7337  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
7338  *	mutually exclusive.
7339  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7340  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7341  *	ranging will be used.
7342  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based
7343  *	ranging measurement (flag)
7344  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
7345  *	mutually exclusive.
7346  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7347  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7348  *	ranging will be used.
7349  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
7350  *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
7351  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7352  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
7353  *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
7354  *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7355  *
7356  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
7357  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7358  */
7359 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
7360 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7361 
7362 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
7363 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
7364 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7365 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
7366 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7367 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7368 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
7369 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
7370 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
7371 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7372 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7373 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
7374 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
7375 
7376 	/* keep last */
7377 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
7378 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
7379 };
7380 
7381 /**
7382  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
7383  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
7384  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
7385  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
7386  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
7387  *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
7388  *	try and get no response)
7389  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
7390  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
7391  *	received
7392  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
7393  *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
7394  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
7395  *	by the peer and are no longer supported
7396  */
7397 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
7398 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
7399 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
7400 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
7401 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
7402 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
7403 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
7404 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
7405 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
7406 };
7407 
7408 /**
7409  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
7410  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7411  *
7412  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
7413  *	(u32, optional)
7414  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
7415  *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
7416  *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
7417  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
7418  *	transmitted (u32, optional)
7419  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
7420  *	that were acknowleged (u32, optional)
7421  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
7422  *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
7423  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
7424  *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7425  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
7426  *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
7427  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
7428  *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7429  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
7430  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7431  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
7432  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7433  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
7434  *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
7435  *	attributes)
7436  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
7437  *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
7438  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
7439  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7440  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7441  *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7442  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7443  *	optional)
7444  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7445  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7446  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7447  *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7448  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7449  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7450  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7451  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7452  *	Type 8.
7453  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7454  *	(binary, optional);
7455  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7456  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7457  *	Type 11.
7458  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7459  *
7460  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7461  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7462  */
7463 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7464 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7465 
7466 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7467 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7468 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7469 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7470 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7471 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7472 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7473 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7474 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7475 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7476 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7477 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7478 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7479 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7480 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7481 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7482 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7483 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7484 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7485 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7486 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7487 
7488 	/* keep last */
7489 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7490 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7491 };
7492 
7493 /**
7494  * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7495  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7496  *
7497  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7498  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7499  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7500  *	tx power offset.
7501  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7502  *	values used by members of the SRG.
7503  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7504  *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7505  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7506  *
7507  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7508  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7509  */
7510 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7511 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7512 
7513 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7514 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7515 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7516 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7517 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7518 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7519 
7520 	/* keep last */
7521 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7522 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7523 };
7524 
7525 /**
7526  * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7527  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7528  *
7529  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7530  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7531  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7532  *
7533  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7534  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7535  */
7536 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7537 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7538 
7539 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7540 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7541 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7542 
7543 	/* keep last */
7544 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7545 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7546 };
7547 
7548 /**
7549  * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7550  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7551  *
7552  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7553  *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7554  *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7555  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7556  *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7557  *
7558  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7559  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7560  */
7561 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7562 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7563 
7564 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7565 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7566 
7567 	/* keep last */
7568 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7569 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7570 };
7571 
7572 /**
7573  * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7574  * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7575  *
7576  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7577  *
7578  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7579  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7580  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7581  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7582  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7583  *	frame including the headers.
7584  *
7585  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7586  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7587  */
7588 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7589 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7590 
7591 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7592 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7593 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7594 
7595 	/* keep last */
7596 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7597 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7598 };
7599 
7600 /*
7601  * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7602  * mandatory fields.
7603  */
7604 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7605 
7606 /**
7607  * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7608  *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7609  *
7610  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7611  *
7612  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7613  *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7614  *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning).
7615  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7616  *	frame template (binary).
7617  *
7618  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7619  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7620  */
7621 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7622 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7623 
7624 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7625 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7626 
7627 	/* keep last */
7628 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7629 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7630 		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7631 };
7632 
7633 /**
7634  * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7635  *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7636  *	used.
7637  *
7638  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7639  *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7640  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7641  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7642  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7643  *	can be used.
7644  */
7645 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7646 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7647 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7648 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7649 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7650 };
7651 
7652 /**
7653  * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7654  *
7655  * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7656  *
7657  */
7658 enum nl80211_sar_type {
7659 	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7660 
7661 	/* add new type here */
7662 
7663 	/* Keep last */
7664 	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7665 };
7666 
7667 /**
7668  * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7669  *
7670  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7671  *
7672  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7673  *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7674  *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7675  *
7676  *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7677  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7678  *
7679  *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7680  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7681  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7682  *
7683  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7684  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7685  *
7686  * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7687  */
7688 enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7689 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7690 
7691 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7692 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7693 
7694 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7695 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7696 };
7697 
7698 /**
7699  * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7700  *
7701  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7702  *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7703  *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7704  *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7705  *
7706  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7707  *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7708  *	is applied to this range.
7709  *
7710  *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
7711  *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
7712  *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
7713  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
7714  *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
7715  *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
7716  *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
7717  *
7718  *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
7719  *
7720  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
7721  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7722  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7723  *
7724  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
7725  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7726  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7727  *
7728  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
7729  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
7730  */
7731 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
7732 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
7733 
7734 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
7735 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
7736 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
7737 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
7738 
7739 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
7740 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
7741 };
7742 
7743 /**
7744  * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
7745  * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
7746  * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
7747  * MBSSID and EMA.
7748  * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
7749  * features.
7750  *
7751  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7752  *
7753  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
7754  *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
7755  *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
7756  *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
7757  *
7758  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
7759  *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
7760  *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
7761  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
7762  *	a non-zero value.
7763  *
7764  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
7765  *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
7766  *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
7767  *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
7768  *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
7769  *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
7770  *
7771  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
7772  *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
7773  *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
7774  *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
7775  *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
7776  *	the interface index of the same.
7777  *
7778  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
7779  *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
7780  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
7781  *
7782  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7783  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7784  */
7785 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
7786 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
7787 
7788 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
7789 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
7790 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
7791 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
7792 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
7793 
7794 	/* keep last */
7795 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
7796 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7797 };
7798 
7799 /**
7800  * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
7801  *
7802  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
7803  *	authentication.
7804  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
7805  *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
7806  *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
7807  *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
7808  *	userspace.
7809  */
7810 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
7811 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
7812 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
7813 };
7814 
7815 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
7816